xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision a71ace35)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  *
344  */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 
379 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
380 };
381 
382 /*
383  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
384  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
385  * filtering will be disabled.
386  */
387 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
388 
389 /**
390  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
391  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
392  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
393  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
394  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
395  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
396  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
397  */
398 enum ieee80211_event_type {
399 	RSSI_EVENT,
400 	MLME_EVENT,
401 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
402 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
403 };
404 
405 /**
406  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
407  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
408  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
409  */
410 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
411 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
412 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
413 };
414 
415 /**
416  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
417  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
418  */
419 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
420 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
421 };
422 
423 /**
424  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
425  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
426  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
427  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
428  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
429  */
430 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
431 	AUTH_EVENT,
432 	ASSOC_EVENT,
433 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
434 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
435 };
436 
437 /**
438  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
439  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
440  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
441  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
442  */
443 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
444 	MLME_SUCCESS,
445 	MLME_DENIED,
446 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
447 };
448 
449 /**
450  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
451  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
452  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
453  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
454  */
455 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
456 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
457 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
458 	u16 reason;
459 };
460 
461 /**
462  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
463  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
464  * @tid: the tid
465  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
466  */
467 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
468 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
469 	u16 tid;
470 	u16 ssn;
471 };
472 
473 /**
474  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
475  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
476  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
477  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
478  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
479  * @u:union holding the fields above
480  */
481 struct ieee80211_event {
482 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
483 	union {
484 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
485 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
486 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
487 	} u;
488 };
489 
490 /**
491  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
492  *
493  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
494  *
495  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
496  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
497  */
498 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
499 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
500 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
501 };
502 
503 /**
504  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
505  *
506  * @lci: LCI subelement content
507  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
508  * @lci_len: LCI data length
509  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
510  */
511 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
512 	const u8 *lci;
513 	const u8 *civicloc;
514 	size_t lci_len;
515 	size_t civicloc_len;
516 };
517 
518 /**
519  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
520  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
521  *
522  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
523  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524  */
525 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
526 	u32 min_interval;
527 	u32 max_interval;
528 };
529 
530 /**
531  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
532  *
533  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
534  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
535  *
536  * @addr: (link) address used locally
537  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
538  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
539  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
540  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
541  *	ACK, BACK or both
542  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
543  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
544  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
545  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
546  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
547  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
550  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
551  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
552  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
553  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
554  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
555  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
556  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
557  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
558  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
559  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
560  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
561  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
562  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
563  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
564  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
565  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
566  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
567  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
568  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
569  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
570  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
571  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
572  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
573  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
574  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
575  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
576  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
577  *	the current band.
578  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
579  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
580  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
581  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
582  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
583  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
584  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
585  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
586  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
587  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
588  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
589  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
590  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
591  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
592  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
593  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
594  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
595  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
596  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
597  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
598  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
599  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
600  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
601  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
602  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
603  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
604  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
605  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
606  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
607  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
608  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
609  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
610  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
611  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
612  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
613  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
614  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
615  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
616  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
617  *	station.
618  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
619  *	responder functionality.
620  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
621  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
622  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
623  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
624  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
625  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
626  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
627  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
628  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
629  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
630  *	connected to (STA)
631  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
632  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
633  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
634  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
635  *	interval.
636  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
637  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
638  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
639  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
640  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
641  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
642  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
643  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
644  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
645  *	for read access.
646  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
647  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
648  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
649  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
650  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
651  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
652  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
653  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
654  *	for read access.
655  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
656  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
657  *	beamformer
658  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
659  *	beamformee
660  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
661  *	beamformer
662  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
663  *	beamformee
664  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
665  *	beamformer
666  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
667  *	beamformee
668  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
669  *	beamformer
670  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
671  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
672  *	bandwidth
673  */
674 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
675 	const u8 *bssid;
676 	unsigned int link_id;
677 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
678 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
679 	bool uora_exists;
680 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
681 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
682 	bool he_support;
683 	bool twt_requester;
684 	bool twt_responder;
685 	bool twt_protected;
686 	bool twt_broadcast;
687 	/* erp related data */
688 	bool use_cts_prot;
689 	bool use_short_preamble;
690 	bool use_short_slot;
691 	bool enable_beacon;
692 	u8 dtim_period;
693 	u16 beacon_int;
694 	u16 assoc_capability;
695 	u64 sync_tsf;
696 	u32 sync_device_ts;
697 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
698 	u32 basic_rates;
699 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
700 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
701 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
702 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
703 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
704 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
705 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
706 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
707 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
708 	bool qos;
709 	bool hidden_ssid;
710 	int txpower;
711 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
712 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
713 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
714 	u16 max_idle_period;
715 	bool protected_keep_alive;
716 	bool ftm_responder;
717 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
718 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
719 	bool nontransmitted;
720 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
721 	u8 bssid_index;
722 	u8 bssid_indicator;
723 	bool ema_ap;
724 	u8 profile_periodicity;
725 	struct {
726 		u32 params;
727 		u16 nss_set;
728 	} he_oper;
729 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
730 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
731 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
732 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
733 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
734 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
735 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
736 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
737 	u8 pwr_reduction;
738 	bool eht_support;
739 
740 	bool csa_active;
741 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
742 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
743 
744 	bool color_change_active;
745 	u8 color_change_color;
746 
747 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
748 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
749 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
750 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
751 	bool he_su_beamformer;
752 	bool he_su_beamformee;
753 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
754 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
755 };
756 
757 /**
758  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
759  *
760  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
761  *
762  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
763  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
764  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
765  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
766  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
767  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
768  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
769  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
770  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
771  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
772  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
773  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
774  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
775  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
776  *	station
777  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
778  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
779  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
780  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
781  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
782  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
783  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
784  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
785  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
786  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
787  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
788  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
789  *	hardware queue.
790  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
791  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
792  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
793  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
794  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
795  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
796  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
797  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
798  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
799  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
800  *	off-channel operation.
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
802  *	(header conversion)
803  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
804  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
805  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
806  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
807  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
808  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
809  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
810  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
811  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
812  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
813  *	queue gets full.
814  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
815  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
816  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
817  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
818  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
819  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
820  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
821  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
822  *	status to user space)
823  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
824  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
825  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
826  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
827  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
828  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
829  *	handled properly by the device.
830  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
831  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
832  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
833  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
834  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
835  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
836  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
837  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
838  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
839  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
840  *	PS-Poll responses.
841  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
842  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
843  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
845  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
846  *	monitor injection).
847  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
848  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
849  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
850  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
851  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
852  *
853  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
854  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
855  */
856 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
857 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
858 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
859 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
860 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
861 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
862 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
863 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
864 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
865 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
866 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
867 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
868 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
869 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
870 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
871 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
872 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
873 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
874 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
875 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
876 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
877 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
878 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
879 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
880 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
888 };
889 
890 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
891 
892 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
893 
894 /**
895  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
896  *
897  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
898  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
899  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
900  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
901  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
902  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
903  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
904  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
905  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
906  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
907  *	it can be sent out.
908  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
909  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
910  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
911  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
912  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
913  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
914  *	for sequence number assignment
915  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
916  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
917  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
918  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
919  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
920  *	it's intended for an MLD.
921  *
922  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
923  */
924 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
925 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
926 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
927 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
928 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
929 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
930 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
931 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
932 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
933 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
934 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
935 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
936 };
937 
938 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
939 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
940 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
941 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
942 
943 /**
944  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
945  *
946  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
947  *
948  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
949  */
950 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
951 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
952 };
953 
954 /*
955  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
956  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
957  */
958 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
959 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
960 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
961 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
962 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
963 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
964 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
965 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
966 
967 /**
968  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
969  *	Rate Control algorithm.
970  *
971  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
972  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
973  *
974  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
975  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
976  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
977  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
978  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
979  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
980  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
981  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
982  *	Greenfield mode.
983  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
984  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
985  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
986  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
988  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
989  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
990  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
991  */
992 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
993 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
994 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
995 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
996 
997 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
998 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
999 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1000 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1001 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1002 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1003 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1004 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1005 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1006 };
1007 
1008 
1009 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1010 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1011 
1012 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1013 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1014 
1015 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1016 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1017 
1018 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1019 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1020 
1021 /**
1022  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1023  *
1024  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1025  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1026  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1027  *
1028  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1029  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1030  *
1031  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1032  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1033  *
1034  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1035  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1036  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1037  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1038  * information::
1039  *
1040  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1041  *
1042  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1043  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1044  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1045  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1046  * information should then contain::
1047  *
1048  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1049  *
1050  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1051  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1052  */
1053 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1054 	s8 idx;
1055 	u16 count:5,
1056 	    flags:11;
1057 } __packed;
1058 
1059 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1060 
1061 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1062 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1063 {
1064 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1065 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1066 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1067 }
1068 
1069 static inline u8
1070 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1071 {
1072 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1073 }
1074 
1075 static inline u8
1076 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1077 {
1078 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1079 }
1080 
1081 /**
1082  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1083  *
1084  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1085  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1086  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1087  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1088  *
1089  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1090  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1091  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1092  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1093  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1094  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1095  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1096  * @control: union part for control data
1097  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1098  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1099  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1100  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1101  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1102  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1103  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1104  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1105  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1106  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1107  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1108  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1109  * @pad: padding
1110  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1111  * @status: union part for status data
1112  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1113  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1114  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1115  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1116  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1117  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1118  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1119  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1120  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1121  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1122  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1123  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1124  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1125  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1126  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1127  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1128  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1129  */
1130 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1131 	/* common information */
1132 	u32 flags;
1133 	u32 band:3,
1134 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1135 	    hw_queue:4,
1136 	    tx_time_est:10;
1137 	/* 2 free bits */
1138 
1139 	union {
1140 		struct {
1141 			union {
1142 				/* rate control */
1143 				struct {
1144 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1145 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1146 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1147 					u8 use_rts:1;
1148 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1149 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1150 					u8 skip_table:1;
1151 					/* 2 bytes free */
1152 				};
1153 				/* only needed before rate control */
1154 				unsigned long jiffies;
1155 			};
1156 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1157 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1158 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1159 			u32 flags;
1160 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1161 		} control;
1162 		struct {
1163 			u64 cookie;
1164 		} ack;
1165 		struct {
1166 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1167 			s32 ack_signal;
1168 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1169 			u8 ampdu_len;
1170 			u8 antenna;
1171 			u16 tx_time;
1172 			u8 flags;
1173 			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1174 		} status;
1175 		struct {
1176 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1177 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1178 			u8 pad[4];
1179 
1180 			void *rate_driver_data[
1181 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1182 		};
1183 		void *driver_data[
1184 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1185 	};
1186 };
1187 
1188 static inline u16
1189 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1190 {
1191 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1192 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1193 	 */
1194 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1195 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1196 }
1197 
1198 static inline u16
1199 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1200 {
1201 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1202 }
1203 
1204 /***
1205  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1206  *
1207  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1208  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1209  *
1210  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1211  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1212  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1213  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1214  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1215  */
1216 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1217 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1218 	u8 try_count;
1219 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1220 };
1221 
1222 /**
1223  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1224  *
1225  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1226  * @info: Basic tx status information
1227  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1228  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1229  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1230  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1231  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1232  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1233  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1234  */
1235 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1236 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1237 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1238 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1239 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1240 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1241 	u8 n_rates;
1242 
1243 	struct list_head *free_list;
1244 };
1245 
1246 /**
1247  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1248  *
1249  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1250  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1251  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1252  *
1253  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1254  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1255  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1256  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1257  */
1258 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1259 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1260 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1261 	const u8 *common_ies;
1262 	size_t common_ie_len;
1263 };
1264 
1265 
1266 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1267 {
1268 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1269 }
1270 
1271 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1272 {
1273 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1274 }
1275 
1276 /**
1277  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1278  *
1279  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1280  *
1281  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1282  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1283  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1284  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1285  *
1286  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1287  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1288  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1289  */
1290 static inline void
1291 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1292 {
1293 	int i;
1294 
1295 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1296 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1297 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1298 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1299 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1300 	/* clear the rate counts */
1301 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1302 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1303 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1304 }
1305 
1306 
1307 /**
1308  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1309  *
1310  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1311  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1312  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1313  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1314  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1315  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1316  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1317  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1318  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1319  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1320  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1321  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1322  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1323  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1324  *	de-duplication by itself.
1325  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1326  *	the frame.
1327  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1328  *	the frame.
1329  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1330  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1331  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1332  *	merging.
1333  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1334  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1335  *	(including FCS) was received.
1336  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1337  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1338  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1339  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1340  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1341  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1342  *	each A-MPDU
1343  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1344  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1345  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1346  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1347  *	on this subframe
1348  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1349  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1350  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1351  *	done by the hardware
1352  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1353  *	processing it in any regular way.
1354  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1355  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1356  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1357  *	monitor interfaces.
1358  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1359  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1360  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1361  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1362  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1363  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1364  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1365  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1366  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1367  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1368  *	interleaved with other frames.
1369  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1370  *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1371  *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1372  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1373  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1374  *	the first subframe.
1375  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1376  *	be done in the hardware.
1377  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1378  *	frame
1379  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1380  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1381  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1382  *
1383  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1384  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1385  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1386  *	 - DATA5_GI
1387  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1388  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1389  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1390  *
1391  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1392  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1393  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1394  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1395  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1396  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1397  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1398  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1399  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1400  *	hardware or driver)
1401  */
1402 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1403 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1404 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1405 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1406 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1407 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1408 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1409 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1410 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1411 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1412 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1413 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1414 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1415 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1416 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1417 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1418 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1419 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1420 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1421 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1422 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1423 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1424 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1425 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1426 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1427 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1428 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1429 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1430 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1431 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1432 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1433 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1434 };
1435 
1436 /**
1437  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1438  *
1439  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1440  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1441  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1442  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1443  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1444  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1445  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1446  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1447  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1448  */
1449 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1450 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1451 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1452 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1453 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1454 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1455 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1456 };
1457 
1458 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1459 
1460 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1461 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1462 	RX_ENC_HT,
1463 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1464 	RX_ENC_HE,
1465 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1466 };
1467 
1468 /**
1469  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1470  *
1471  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1472  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1473  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1474  *
1475  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1476  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1477  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1478  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1479  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1480  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1481  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1482  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1483  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1484  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1485  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1486  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1487  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1488  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1489  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1490  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1491  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1492  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1493  *	values were filled.
1494  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1495  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1496  * @antenna: antenna used
1497  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1498  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1499  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1500  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1501  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1502  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1503  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1504  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1505  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1506  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1507  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1508  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1509  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1510  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1511  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1512  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1513  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1514  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1515  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1516  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1517  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1518  *	@link_valid.
1519  */
1520 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1521 	u64 mactime;
1522 	union {
1523 		u64 boottime_ns;
1524 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1525 	};
1526 	u32 device_timestamp;
1527 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1528 	u32 flag;
1529 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1530 	u8 enc_flags;
1531 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1532 	union {
1533 		struct {
1534 			u8 he_ru:3;
1535 			u8 he_gi:2;
1536 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1537 		};
1538 		struct {
1539 			u8 ru:4;
1540 			u8 gi:2;
1541 		} eht;
1542 	};
1543 	u8 rate_idx;
1544 	u8 nss;
1545 	u8 rx_flags;
1546 	u8 band;
1547 	u8 antenna;
1548 	s8 signal;
1549 	u8 chains;
1550 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1551 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1552 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1553 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1554 };
1555 
1556 static inline u32
1557 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1558 {
1559 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1560 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1561 }
1562 
1563 /**
1564  * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1565  * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1566  *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1567  *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1568  * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1569  *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1570  *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1571  *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1572  * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1573  * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1574  * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1575  *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1576  *	@data field.
1577  * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1578  *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1579  *	length
1580  * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1581  *
1582  * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1583  * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1584  * data.
1585  */
1586 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1587 	u32 present;
1588 	u8 align;
1589 	u8 oui[3];
1590 	u8 subns;
1591 	u8 pad;
1592 	u16 len;
1593 	u8 data[];
1594 } __packed;
1595 
1596 /**
1597  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1598  *
1599  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1600  *
1601  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1602  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1603  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1604  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1605  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1606  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1607  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1608  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1609  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1610  *	for more.
1611  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1612  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1613  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1614  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1615  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1616  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1617  *	operating channel.
1618  */
1619 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1620 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1621 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1622 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1623 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1624 };
1625 
1626 
1627 /**
1628  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1629  *
1630  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1631  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1632  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1633  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1634  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1635  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1636  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1637  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1638  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1639  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1640  */
1641 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1642 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1643 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1644 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1645 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1646 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1647 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1648 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1649 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1650 };
1651 
1652 /**
1653  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1654  *
1655  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1656  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1657  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1658  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1659  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1660  */
1661 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1662 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1663 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1664 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1665 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1666 
1667 	/* keep last */
1668 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1669 };
1670 
1671 /**
1672  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1673  *
1674  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1675  *
1676  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1677  *
1678  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1679  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1680  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1681  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1682  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1683  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1684  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1685  *
1686  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1687  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1688  *
1689  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1690  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1691  *
1692  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1693  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1694  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1695  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1696  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1697  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1698  *
1699  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1700  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1701  *	configured for an HT channel.
1702  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1703  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1704  */
1705 struct ieee80211_conf {
1706 	u32 flags;
1707 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1708 
1709 	u16 listen_interval;
1710 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1711 
1712 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1713 
1714 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1715 	bool radar_enabled;
1716 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1717 };
1718 
1719 /**
1720  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1721  *
1722  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1723  * operation.
1724  *
1725  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1726  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1727  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1728  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1729  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1730  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1731  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1732  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1733  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1734  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1735  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1736   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1737   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1738  */
1739 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1740 	u64 timestamp;
1741 	u32 device_timestamp;
1742 	bool block_tx;
1743 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1744 	u8 count;
1745 	u32 delay;
1746 };
1747 
1748 /**
1749  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1750  *
1751  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1752  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1753  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1754  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1755  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1756  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1757  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1758  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1759  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1760  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1761  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1762  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1763  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1764  */
1765 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1766 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1767 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1768 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1769 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1770 };
1771 
1772 
1773 /**
1774  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1775  *
1776  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1777  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1778  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1779  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1780  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1781  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1782  *	mac80211.
1783  */
1784 
1785 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1786 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1787 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1788 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1789 };
1790 
1791 /**
1792  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1793  * @assoc: association status
1794  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1795  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1796  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1797  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1798  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1799  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1800  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1801  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1802  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1803  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1804  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1805  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1806  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1807  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1808  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1809  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1810  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1811  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1812  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1813  *	(station mode only)
1814  */
1815 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1816 	/* association related data */
1817 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1818 	bool ibss_creator;
1819 	bool ps;
1820 	u16 aid;
1821 
1822 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1823 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1824 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1825 	size_t ssid_len;
1826 	bool s1g;
1827 	bool idle;
1828 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1829 };
1830 
1831 /**
1832  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1833  *
1834  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1835  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1836  *
1837  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1838  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1839  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1840  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1841  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1842  *	indexed by link ID
1843  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1844  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1845  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1846  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1847  * @addr: address of this interface
1848  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1849  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1850  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1851  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1852  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1853  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1854  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1855  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1856  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1857  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1858  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1859  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1860  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1861  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1862  *	restrictions.
1863  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1864  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1865  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1866  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1867  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1868  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1869  *	interface.
1870  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1871  *	for this interface.
1872  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1873  *	sizeof(void \*).
1874  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1875  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1876  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1877  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1878  */
1879 struct ieee80211_vif {
1880 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1881 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1882 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1883 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1884 	u16 valid_links, active_links;
1885 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1886 	bool p2p;
1887 
1888 	u8 cab_queue;
1889 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1890 
1891 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1892 
1893 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1894 	u32 driver_flags;
1895 	u32 offload_flags;
1896 
1897 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1898 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1899 #endif
1900 
1901 	bool probe_req_reg;
1902 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1903 
1904 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1905 
1906 	/* must be last */
1907 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1908 };
1909 
1910 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1911 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1912 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1913 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1914 		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1915 
1916 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1917 {
1918 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1919 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1920 #endif
1921 	return false;
1922 }
1923 
1924 /**
1925  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1926  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1927  *
1928  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1929  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1930  *
1931  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1932  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1933  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1934  */
1935 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1936 
1937 /**
1938  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1939  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1940  *
1941  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1942  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1943  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1944  */
1945 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1946 
1947 /**
1948  * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1949  * @vif: the interface to check
1950  */
1951 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1952 {
1953 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1954 }
1955 
1956 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1957 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1958 				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1959 
1960 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1961 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1962 			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1963 
1964 /**
1965  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1966  *
1967  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1968  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1969  *
1970  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1971  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1972  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1973  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1974  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1975  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1976  *	generation in software.
1977  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1978  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1979  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1980  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1981  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1982  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1983  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1984  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1985  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1986  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1987  *	MIC.
1988  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1989  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1990  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1991  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1992  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1993  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1994  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1995  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1996  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1997  *	only for management frames (MFP).
1998  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1999  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2000  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2001  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2002  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2003  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2004  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2005  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2006  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2007  *	generation only
2008  */
2009 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2010 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2011 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2012 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2013 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2014 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2015 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2016 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2017 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2018 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2019 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2020 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2021 };
2022 
2023 /**
2024  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2025  *
2026  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2027  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2028  *
2029  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2030  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2031  *	encrypted in hardware.
2032  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2033  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2034  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2035  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2036  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2037  * @keylen: key material length
2038  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2039  * 	data block:
2040  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2041  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2042  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2043  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2044  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2045  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2046  */
2047 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2048 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2049 	u32 cipher;
2050 	u8 icv_len;
2051 	u8 iv_len;
2052 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2053 	s8 keyidx;
2054 	u16 flags;
2055 	s8 link_id;
2056 	u8 keylen;
2057 	u8 key[];
2058 };
2059 
2060 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2061 
2062 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2063 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2064 
2065 /**
2066  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2067  *
2068  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2069  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2070  *	reverse order than in packet)
2071  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2072  *	reverse order than in packet)
2073  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2074  *	reverse order than in packet)
2075  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2076  *	reverse order than in packet)
2077  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2078  */
2079 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2080 	union {
2081 		struct {
2082 			u32 iv32;
2083 			u16 iv16;
2084 		} tkip;
2085 		struct {
2086 			u8 pn[6];
2087 		} ccmp;
2088 		struct {
2089 			u8 pn[6];
2090 		} aes_cmac;
2091 		struct {
2092 			u8 pn[6];
2093 		} aes_gmac;
2094 		struct {
2095 			u8 pn[6];
2096 		} gcmp;
2097 		struct {
2098 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2099 			u8 seq_len;
2100 		} hw;
2101 	};
2102 };
2103 
2104 /**
2105  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2106  *
2107  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2108  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2109  *
2110  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2111  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2112  */
2113 enum set_key_cmd {
2114 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2115 };
2116 
2117 /**
2118  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2119  *
2120  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2121  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2122  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2123  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2124  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2125  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2126  */
2127 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2128 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2129 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2130 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2131 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2132 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2133 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2134 };
2135 
2136 /**
2137  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2138  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2139  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2140  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2141  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2142  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2143  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2144  *
2145  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2146  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2147  */
2148 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2149 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2150 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2151 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2152 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2153 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2154 };
2155 
2156 /**
2157  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2158  *
2159  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2160  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2161  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2162  */
2163 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2164 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2165 	struct {
2166 		s8 idx;
2167 		u8 count;
2168 		u8 count_cts;
2169 		u8 count_rts;
2170 		u16 flags;
2171 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2172 };
2173 
2174 /**
2175  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2176  *
2177  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2178  *
2179  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2180  *	to the STA.
2181  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2182  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2183  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2184  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2185  *	per peer TPC.
2186  */
2187 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2188 	s16 power;
2189 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2190 };
2191 
2192 /**
2193  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2194  *
2195  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2196  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2197  *
2198  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2199  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2200  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2201  *
2202  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2203  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2204  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2205  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2206  *
2207  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2208  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2209  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2210  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2211  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2212  */
2213 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2214 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2215 
2216 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2217 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2218 };
2219 
2220 /**
2221  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2222  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2223  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2224  *
2225  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2226  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2227  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2228  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2229  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2230  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2231  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2232  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2233  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2234  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2235  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2236  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2237  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2238  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2239  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2240  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2241  *	the station moves to associated state.
2242  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2243  *
2244  */
2245 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2246 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2247 
2248 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2249 	u8 link_id;
2250 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2251 
2252 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2253 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2254 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2255 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2256 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2257 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2258 
2259 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2260 
2261 	u8 rx_nss;
2262 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2263 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2264 };
2265 
2266 /**
2267  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2268  *
2269  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2270  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2271  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2272  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2273  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2274  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2275  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2276  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2277  *
2278  * @addr: MAC address
2279  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2280  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2281  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2282  *	Can be modified by driver.
2283  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2284  *	otherwise always false)
2285  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2286  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2287  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2288  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2289  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2290  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2291  * @rates: rate control selection table
2292  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2293  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2294  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2295  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2296  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2297  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2298  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2299  *	unlimited.
2300  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2301  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2302  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2303  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2304  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2305  *	is used for non-data frames
2306  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2307  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2308  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2309  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2310  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2311  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2312  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2313  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2314  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2315  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2316  *	by the AP.
2317  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2318  */
2319 struct ieee80211_sta {
2320 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2321 	u16 aid;
2322 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2323 	bool wme;
2324 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2325 	u8 max_sp;
2326 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2327 	bool tdls;
2328 	bool tdls_initiator;
2329 	bool mfp;
2330 	bool mlo;
2331 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2332 
2333 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2334 
2335 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2336 
2337 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2338 
2339 	u16 valid_links;
2340 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2341 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2342 
2343 	/* must be last */
2344 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2345 };
2346 
2347 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2348 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2349 #else
2350 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2351 {
2352 	return true;
2353 }
2354 #endif
2355 
2356 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2357 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2358 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2359 
2360 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2361 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2362 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2363 
2364 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2365 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2366 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2367 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2368 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2369 
2370 /**
2371  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2372  *
2373  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2374  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2375  *
2376  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2377  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2378  */
2379 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2380 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2381 };
2382 
2383 /**
2384  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2385  *
2386  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2387  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2388  */
2389 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2390 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2391 };
2392 
2393 /**
2394  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2395  *
2396  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2397  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2398  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2399  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2400  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2401  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2402  *
2403  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2404  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2405  */
2406 struct ieee80211_txq {
2407 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2408 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2409 	u8 tid;
2410 	u8 ac;
2411 
2412 	/* must be last */
2413 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2414 };
2415 
2416 /**
2417  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2418  *
2419  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2420  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2421  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2422  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2423  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2424  *
2425  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2426  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2427  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2428  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2429  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2430  *	algorithm.
2431  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2432  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2433  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2434  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2435  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2436  *	CCK frames.
2437  *
2438  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2439  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2440  *	the FCS at the end.
2441  *
2442  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2443  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2444  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2445  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2446  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2447  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2448  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2449  *
2450  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2451  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2452  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2453  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2454  *
2455  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2456  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2457  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2458  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2459  *
2460  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2461  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2462  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2463  *
2464  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2465  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2466  *
2467  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2468  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2469  *
2470  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2471  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2472  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2473  *
2474  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2475  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2476  *
2477  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2478  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2479  *
2480  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2481  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2482  *	the stack.
2483  *
2484  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2485  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2486  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2487  *
2488  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2489  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2490  *	dtim_period).
2491  *
2492  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2493  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2494  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2495  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2496  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2497  *	only in that case.
2498  *
2499  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2500  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2501  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2502  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2503  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2504  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2505  *
2506  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2507  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2508  *	software.
2509  *
2510  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2511  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2512  *	active interfaces.
2513  *
2514  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2515  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2516  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2517  *
2518  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2519  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2520  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2521  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2522  *	supported cipher suites.
2523  *
2524  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2525  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2526  *	for frames.
2527  *
2528  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2529  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2530  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2531  *	control for more details.
2532  *
2533  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2534  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2535  *
2536  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2537  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2538  *	is supported.
2539  *
2540  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2541  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2542  *
2543  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2544  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2545  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2546  *
2547  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2548  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2549  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2550  *	CSA frame.
2551  *
2552  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2553  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2554  *
2555  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2556  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2557  *
2558  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2559  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2560  *
2561  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2562  *	within A-MPDU.
2563  *
2564  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2565  *	for sent beacons.
2566  *
2567  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2568  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2569  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2570  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2571  *
2572  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2573  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2574  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2575  *	timeout.
2576  *
2577  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2578  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2579  *
2580  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2581  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2582  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2583  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2584  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2585  *
2586  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2587  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2588  *
2589  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2590  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2591  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2592  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2593  *
2594  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2595  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2596  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2597  *
2598  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2599  *	TDLS links.
2600  *
2601  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2602  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2603  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2604  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2605  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2606  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2607  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2608  *
2609  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2610  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2611  *
2612  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2613  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2614  *
2615  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2616  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2617  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2618  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2619  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2620  *
2621  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2622  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2623  *	TXQs to start with.
2624  *
2625  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2626  *	length in tx status information
2627  *
2628  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2629  *
2630  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2631  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2632  *
2633  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2634  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2635  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2636  *
2637  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2638  *	offload
2639  *
2640  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2641  *	offload
2642  *
2643  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2644  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2645  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2646  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2647  *	the stack.
2648  *
2649  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2650  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2651  *
2652  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2653  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2654  *
2655  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2656  */
2657 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2658 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2659 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2660 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2661 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2662 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2663 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2664 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2665 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2666 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2667 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2668 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2669 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2670 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2671 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2672 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2673 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2674 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2675 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2676 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2677 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2678 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2679 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2680 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2681 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2682 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2683 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2684 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2685 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2686 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2687 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2688 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2689 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2690 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2691 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2692 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2693 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2694 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2695 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2696 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2697 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2698 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2699 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2700 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2701 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2702 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2703 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2704 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2705 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2706 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2707 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2708 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2709 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2710 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2711 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2712 
2713 	/* keep last, obviously */
2714 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2715 };
2716 
2717 /**
2718  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2719  *
2720  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2721  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2722  *
2723  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2724  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2725  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2726  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2727  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2728  *
2729  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2730  *
2731  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2732  *	along with this structure.
2733  *
2734  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2735  *
2736  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2737  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2738  *
2739  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2740  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2741  *
2742  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2743  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2744  *
2745  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2746  *	that HW supports
2747  *
2748  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2749  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2750  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2751  *
2752  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2753  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2754  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2755  *
2756  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2757  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2758  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2759  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2760  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2761  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2762  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2763  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2764  *
2765  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2766  *	can handle.
2767  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2768  *	the hw can report back.
2769  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2770  *
2771  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2772  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2773  *	aggregation.
2774  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2775  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2776  *	it shouldn't be set.
2777  *
2778  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2779  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2780  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2781  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2782  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2783  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2784  *
2785  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2786  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2787  *
2788  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2789  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2790  *
2791  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2792  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2793  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2794  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2795  *
2796  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2797  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2798  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2799  *
2800  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2801  *
2802  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2803  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2804  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2805  *	device_timestamp.
2806  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2807  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2808  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2809  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2810  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2811  *
2812  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2813  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2814  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2815  *
2816  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2817  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2818  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2819  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2820  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2821  *	neither enabled.
2822  *
2823  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2824  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2825  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2826  *
2827  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2828  *	device.
2829  *
2830  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2831  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2832  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2833  *
2834  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2835  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2836  *
2837  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2838  *
2839  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2840  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2841  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2842  *
2843  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2844  */
2845 struct ieee80211_hw {
2846 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2847 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2848 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2849 	void *priv;
2850 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2851 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2852 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2853 	int vif_data_size;
2854 	int sta_data_size;
2855 	int chanctx_data_size;
2856 	int txq_data_size;
2857 	u16 queues;
2858 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2859 	s8 max_signal;
2860 	u8 max_rates;
2861 	u8 max_report_rates;
2862 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2863 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2864 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2865 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2866 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2867 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2868 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2869 	struct {
2870 		int units_pos;
2871 		s16 accuracy;
2872 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2873 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2874 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2875 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2876 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2877 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2878 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2879 	u32 max_mtu;
2880 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2881 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2882 };
2883 
2884 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2885 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2886 {
2887 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2888 }
2889 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2890 
2891 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2892 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2893 {
2894 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2895 }
2896 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2897 
2898 /**
2899  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2900  *
2901  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2902  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2903  */
2904 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2905 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2906 
2907 	/* Keep last */
2908 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2909 };
2910 
2911 /**
2912  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2913  *
2914  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2915  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2916  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2917  * @status: channel-switch response status
2918  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2919  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2920  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2921  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2922  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2923  */
2924 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2925 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2926 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2927 	u8 action_code;
2928 	u32 status;
2929 	u32 timestamp;
2930 	u16 switch_time;
2931 	u16 switch_timeout;
2932 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2933 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2934 };
2935 
2936 /**
2937  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2938  *
2939  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2940  *
2941  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2942  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2943  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2944  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2945  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2946  *
2947  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2948  */
2949 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2950 
2951 /**
2952  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2953  *
2954  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2955  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2956  */
2957 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2958 {
2959 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2960 }
2961 
2962 /**
2963  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2964  *
2965  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2966  * @addr: the address to set
2967  */
2968 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2969 {
2970 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2971 }
2972 
2973 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2974 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2975 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2976 {
2977 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2978 		return NULL;
2979 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2980 }
2981 
2982 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2983 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2984 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2985 {
2986 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2987 		return NULL;
2988 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2989 }
2990 
2991 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2992 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2993 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2994 {
2995 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2996 		return NULL;
2997 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2998 }
2999 
3000 /**
3001  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3002  * @hw: the hardware
3003  * @skb: the skb
3004  *
3005  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3006  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3007  */
3008 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3009 
3010 /**
3011  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3012  *
3013  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3014  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3015  *
3016  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3017  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3018  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3019  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3020  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3021  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3022  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3023  *
3024  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3025  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3026  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3027  *
3028  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3029  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3030  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3031  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3032  *
3033  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3034  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3035  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3036  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3037  *
3038  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3039  *
3040  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3041  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3042  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3043  * based on the receive flags.
3044  *
3045  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3046  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3047  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3048  * keys.
3049  *
3050  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3051  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3052  * handler.
3053  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3054  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3055  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3056  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3057  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3058  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3059  *
3060  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3061  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3062  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3063  *
3064  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3065  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3066  * requirements:
3067  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3068       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3069    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3070       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3071    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3072       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3073       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3074    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3075    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3076  */
3077 
3078 /**
3079  * DOC: Powersave support
3080  *
3081  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3082  *
3083  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3084  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3085  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3086  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3087  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3088  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3089  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3090  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3091  *
3092  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3093  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3094  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3095  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3096  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3097  *
3098  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3099  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3100  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3101  *
3102  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3103  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3104  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3105  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3106  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3107  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3108  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3109  *
3110  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3111  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3112  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3113  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3114  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3115  * periods.
3116  *
3117  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3118  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3119  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3120  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3121  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3122  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3123  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3124  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3125  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3126  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3127  *
3128  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3129  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3130  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3131  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3132  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3133  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3134  *
3135  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3136  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3137  */
3138 
3139 /**
3140  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3141  *
3142  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3143  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3144  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3145  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3146  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3147  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3148  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3149  *
3150  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3151  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3152  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3153  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3154  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3155  *
3156  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3157  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3158  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3159  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3160  *
3161  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3162  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3163  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3164  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3165  *
3166  *  - a list of information element IDs
3167  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3168  *
3169  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3170  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3171  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3172  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3173  * vendor information elements.
3174  *
3175  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3176  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3177  *
3178  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3179  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3180  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3181  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3182  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3183  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3184  *
3185  *
3186  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3187  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3188  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3189  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3190  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3191  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3192  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3193  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3194  *
3195  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3196  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3197  * signal strength threshold checking.
3198  */
3199 
3200 /**
3201  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3202  *
3203  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3204  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3205  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3206  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3207  *
3208  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3209  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3210  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3211  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3212  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3213  * hardware flags.
3214  *
3215  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3216  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3217  * turned off otherwise.
3218  *
3219  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3220  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3221  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3222  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3223  */
3224 
3225 /**
3226  * DOC: Frame filtering
3227  *
3228  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3229  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3230  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3231  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3232  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3233  *
3234  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3235  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3236  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3237  *
3238  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3239  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3240  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3241  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3242  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3243  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3244  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3245  *
3246  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3247  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3248  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3249  * or dropped.
3250  *
3251  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3252  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3253  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3254  * the flag, but not clear it.
3255  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3256  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3257  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3258  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3259  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3260  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3261  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3262  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3263  */
3264 
3265 /**
3266  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3267  *
3268  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3269  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3270  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3271  *
3272  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3273  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3274  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3275  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3276  * the driver code.
3277  *
3278  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3279  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3280  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3281  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3282  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3283  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3284  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3285  *
3286  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3287  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3288  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3289  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3290  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3291  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3292  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3293  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3294  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3295  * @sta_notify callback.
3296  *
3297  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3298  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3299  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3300  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3301  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3302  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3303  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3304  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3305  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3306  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3307  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3308  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3309  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3310  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3311  *
3312  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3313  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3314  *
3315  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3316  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3317  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3318  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3319  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3320  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3321  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3322  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3323  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3324  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3325  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3326  *
3327  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3328  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3329  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3330  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3331  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3332  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3333  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3334  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3335  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3336  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3337  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3338  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3339  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3340  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3341  *
3342  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3343  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3344  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3345  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3346  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3347  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3348  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3349  *
3350  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3351  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3352  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3353  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3354  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3355  *
3356  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3357  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3358  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3359  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3360  */
3361 
3362 /**
3363  * DOC: HW queue control
3364  *
3365  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3366  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3367  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3368  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3369  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3370  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3371  *
3372  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3373  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3374  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3375  *
3376  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3377  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3378  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3379  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3380  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3381  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3382  * the hardware queue.
3383  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3384  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3385  *
3386  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3387  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3388  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3389  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3390  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3391  *
3392  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3393  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3394  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3395  * off-channel queue:         9
3396  *
3397  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3398  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3399  *
3400  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3401  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3402  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3403  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3404  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3405  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3406  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3407  *
3408  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3409  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3410  *
3411  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3412  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3413  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3414  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3415  */
3416 
3417 /**
3418  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3419  *
3420  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3421  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3422  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3423  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3424  *
3425  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3426  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3427  *	multicast address.
3428  *
3429  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3430  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3431  *
3432  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3433  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3434  *
3435  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3436  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3437  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3438  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3439  *	honour this flag if possible.
3440  *
3441  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3442  *	station
3443  *
3444  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3445  *
3446  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3447  *
3448  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3449  *
3450  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3451  */
3452 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3453 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3454 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3455 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3456 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3457 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3458 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3459 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3460 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3461 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3462 };
3463 
3464 /**
3465  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3466  *
3467  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3468  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3469  *
3470  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3471  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3472  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3473  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3474  *
3475  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3476  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3477  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3478  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3479  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3480  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3481  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3482  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3483  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3484  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3485  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3486  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3487  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3488  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3489  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3490  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3491  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3492  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3493  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3494  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3495  */
3496 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3497 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3498 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3499 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3500 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3501 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3502 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3503 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3504 };
3505 
3506 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3507 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3508 
3509 /**
3510  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3511  *
3512  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3513  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3514  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3515  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3516  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3517  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3518  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3519  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3520  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3521  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3522  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3523  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3524  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3525  */
3526 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3527 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3528 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3529 	u16 tid;
3530 	u16 ssn;
3531 	u16 buf_size;
3532 	bool amsdu;
3533 	u16 timeout;
3534 };
3535 
3536 /**
3537  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3538  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3539  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3540  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3541  */
3542 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3543 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3544 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3545 };
3546 
3547 /**
3548  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3549  *
3550  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3551  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3552  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3553  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3554  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3555  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3556  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3557  *	the peer.
3558  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3559  *	by the peer
3560  */
3561 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3562 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3563 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3564 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3565 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3566 };
3567 
3568 /**
3569  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3570  *
3571  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3572  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3573  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3574  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3575  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3576  *
3577  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3578  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3579  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3580  */
3581 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3582 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3583 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3584 };
3585 
3586 /**
3587  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3588  *
3589  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3590  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3591  *
3592  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3593  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3594  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3595  *	of wowlan configuration)
3596  */
3597 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3598 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3599 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3600 };
3601 
3602 /**
3603  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3604  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3605  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3606  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3607  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3608  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3609  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3610  */
3611 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3612 	u16 duration;
3613 	u16 subtype;
3614 	u8 success:1;
3615 };
3616 
3617 /**
3618  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3619  *
3620  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3621  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3622  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3623  *
3624  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3625  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3626  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3627  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3628  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3629  *	Must be atomic.
3630  *
3631  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3632  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3633  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3634  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3635  *	or zero.
3636  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3637  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3638  *	is added.
3639  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3640  *
3641  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3642  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3643  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3644  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3645  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3646  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3647  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3648  *
3649  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3650  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3651  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3652  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3653  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3654  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3655  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3656  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3657  *	must return 1 from this function.
3658  *
3659  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3660  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3661  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3662  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3663  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3664  *
3665  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3666  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3667  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3668  *	in suspend().
3669  *
3670  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3671  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3672  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3673  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3674  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3675  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3676  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3677  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3678  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3679  *
3680  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3681  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3682  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3683  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3684  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3685  *
3686  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3687  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3688  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3689  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3690  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3691  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3692  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3693  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3694  *
3695  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3696  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3697  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3698  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3699  *
3700  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3701  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3702  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3703  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3704  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3705  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3706  *	can sleep.
3707  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3708  *	are not implemented.
3709  *
3710  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3711  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3712  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3713  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3714  *	The callback can sleep.
3715  *
3716  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3717  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3718  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3719  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3720  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3721  *	non-MLO connections.
3722  *	The callback can sleep.
3723  *
3724  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3725  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3726  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3727  *
3728  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3729  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3730  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3731  *
3732  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3733  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3734  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3735  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3736  *	which flags are changed.
3737  *	This callback can sleep.
3738  *
3739  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3740  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3741  *
3742  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3743  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3744  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3745  *	is enabled.
3746  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3747  *	The callback can sleep.
3748  *
3749  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3750  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3751  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3752  *	The callback must be atomic.
3753  *
3754  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3755  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3756  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3757  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3758  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3759  *
3760  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3761  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3762  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3763  *
3764  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3765  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3766  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3767  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3768  *	that power save is disabled.
3769  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3770  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3771  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3772  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3773  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3774  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3775  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3776  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3777  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3778  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3779  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3780  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3781  *	The callback can sleep.
3782  *
3783  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3784  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3785  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3786  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3787  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3788  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3789  *	The callback can sleep.
3790  *
3791  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3792  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3793  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3794  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3795  *
3796  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3797  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3798  *
3799  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3800  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3801  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3802  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3803  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3804  *
3805  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3806  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3807  *	this notification.
3808  *	The callback can sleep.
3809  *
3810  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3811  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3812  *	The callback can sleep.
3813  *
3814  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3815  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3816  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3817  *	The callback must be atomic.
3818  *
3819  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3820  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3821  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3822  *	should be set as well.
3823  *	The callback can sleep.
3824  *
3825  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3826  *	The callback can sleep.
3827  *
3828  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3829  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3830  *
3831  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3832  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3833  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3834  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3835  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3836  *	This callback can sleep.
3837  *
3838  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3839  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3840  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3841  *	callback can sleep.
3842  *
3843  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3844  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3845  *	should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3846  *	callback can sleep.
3847  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3848  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3849  *
3850  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3851  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3852  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3853  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3854  *
3855  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3856  *	power for the station.
3857  *	This callback can sleep.
3858  *
3859  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3860  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3861  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3862  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3863  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3864  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3865  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3866  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3867  *	The callback can sleep.
3868  *
3869  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3870  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3871  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3872  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3873  *	in @sta_state.
3874  *	The callback can sleep.
3875  *
3876  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3877  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3878  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3879  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3880  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3881  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3882  *	Must be atomic.
3883  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3884  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3885  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3886  *
3887  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3888  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3889  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3890  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3891  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3892  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3893  *	The callback can sleep.
3894  *
3895  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3896  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3897  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3898  *	The callback can sleep.
3899  *
3900  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3901  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3902  *	required function.
3903  *	The callback can sleep.
3904  *
3905  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3906  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3907  *	required function.
3908  *	The callback can sleep.
3909  *
3910  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3911  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3912  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3913  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3914  *	The callback can sleep.
3915  *
3916  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3917  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3918  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3919  *	TSF synchronization.
3920  *	The callback can sleep.
3921  *
3922  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3923  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3924  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3925  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3926  *	The callback can sleep.
3927  *
3928  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3929  *
3930  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3931  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3932  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3933  *	The callback can sleep.
3934  *
3935  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3936  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3937  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3938  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3939  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3940  *
3941  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3942  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3943  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3944  *
3945  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3946  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3947  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3948  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3949  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3950  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3951  *	The callback can sleep.
3952  *
3953  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3954  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3955  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3956  *	completion of the channel switch.
3957  *
3958  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3959  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3960  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3961  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3962  *
3963  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3964  *
3965  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3966  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3967  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3968  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3969  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3970  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3971  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3972  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3973  *	must be accepted in this case.
3974  *	This callback may sleep.
3975  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3976  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3977  *
3978  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3979  *
3980  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3981  *
3982  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3983  *	queues before entering power save.
3984  *
3985  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3986  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3987  *	The callback can sleep.
3988  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3989  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3990  *	The callback must be atomic.
3991  *
3992  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3993  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3994  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3995  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3996  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3997  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3998  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3999  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4000  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4001  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4002  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4003  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4004  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4005  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4006  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4007  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4008  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4009  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4010  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4011  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4012  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4013  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4014  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4015  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4016  *	This callback must be atomic.
4017  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4018  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4019  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4020  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4021  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4022  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4023  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4024  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4025  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4026  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4027  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4028  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4029  *	This callback must be atomic.
4030  *
4031  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4032  *
4033  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4034  *
4035  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4036  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4037  *
4038  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4039  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4040  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4041  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4042  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4043  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4044  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4045  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4046  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4047  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4048  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4049  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4050  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4051  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4052  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4053  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4054  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4055  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4056  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4057  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4058  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4059  *
4060  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4061  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4062  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4063  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4064  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4065  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4066  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4067  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4068  *
4069  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4070  *	This callback may sleep.
4071  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4072  *	This callback may sleep.
4073  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4074  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4075  *	channel context with different settings
4076  *	This callback may sleep.
4077  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4078  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4079  *	This callback may sleep.
4080  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4081  *	unbound from vif.
4082  *	This callback may sleep.
4083  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4084  *	another, as specified in the list of
4085  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4086  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4087  *	This callback may sleep.
4088  *
4089  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4090  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4091  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4092  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4093  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4094  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4095  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4096  *
4097  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4098  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4099  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4100  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4101  *	This callback may sleep.
4102  *
4103  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4104  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4105  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4106  *
4107  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4108  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4109  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4110  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4111  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4112  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4113  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4114  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4115  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4116  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4117  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4118  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4119  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4120  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4121  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4122  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4123  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4124  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4125  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4126  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4127  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4128  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4129  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4130  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4131  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4132  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4133  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4134  *
4135  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4136  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4137  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4138  *
4139  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4140  *	and hardware limits.
4141  *
4142  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4143  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4144  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4145  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4146  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4147  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4148  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4149  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4150  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4151  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4152  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4153  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4154  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4155  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4156  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4157  *	the function call.
4158  *
4159  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4160  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4161  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4162  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4163  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4164  *
4165  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4166  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4167  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4168  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4169  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4170  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4171  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4172  *	changed parameters.
4173  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4174  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4175  *	this call.
4176  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4177  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4178  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4179  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4180  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4181  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4182  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4183  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4184  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4185  *
4186  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4187  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4188  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4189  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4190  *	This callback may sleep.
4191  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4192  *	This callback may sleep.
4193  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4194  *	4-address mode
4195  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4196  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4197  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4198  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4199  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4200  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4201  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4202  *	twt structure.
4203  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4204  *	from the peer.
4205  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4206  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4207  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4208  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4209  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4210  *	radar channel.
4211  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4212  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4213  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4214  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4215  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4216  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4217  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4218  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4219  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4220  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4221  *	This callback can sleep.
4222  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4223  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4224  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4225  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4226  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4227  */
4228 struct ieee80211_ops {
4229 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4230 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4231 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4232 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4233 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4234 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4235 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4236 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4237 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4238 #endif
4239 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4240 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4241 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4242 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4243 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4244 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4245 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4246 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4247 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4248 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4249 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4250 				 u64 changed);
4251 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4252 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4253 				u64 changed);
4254 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4255 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4256 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4257 				  u64 changed);
4258 
4259 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4260 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4261 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4262 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4263 
4264 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4265 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4266 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4267 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4268 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4269 				 u64 multicast);
4270 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4271 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4272 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4273 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4274 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4275 		       bool set);
4276 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4277 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4278 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4279 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4280 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4281 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4282 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4283 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4284 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4285 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4286 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4287 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4288 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4289 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4290 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4291 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4292 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4293 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4294 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4295 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4296 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4297 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4298 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4299 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4300 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4301 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4302 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4303 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4304 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4305 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4306 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4307 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4308 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4309 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4310 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4311 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4312 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4313 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4314 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4315 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4316 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4317 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4318 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4319 				struct dentry *dir);
4320 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4321 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4322 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4323 				     struct dentry *dir);
4324 #endif
4325 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4326 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4327 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4328 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4329 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4330 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4331 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4332 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4333 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4334 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4335 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4336 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4337 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4338 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4339 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4340 			      u32 changed);
4341 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4342 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4343 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4344 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4346 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4347 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4348 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4349 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4350 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4351 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4352 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4353 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4354 			u64 tsf);
4355 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4356 			   s64 offset);
4357 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4358 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4359 
4360 	/**
4361 	 * @ampdu_action:
4362 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4363 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4364 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4365 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4366 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4367 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4368 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4369 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4370 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4371 	 *
4372 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4373 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4374 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4375 	 *
4376 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4377 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4378 	 *
4379 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4380 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4381 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4382 	 *
4383 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4384 	 *
4385 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4386 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4387 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4388 	 *
4389 	 * The callback can sleep.
4390 	 */
4391 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4392 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4393 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4394 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4395 		struct survey_info *survey);
4396 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4397 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4398 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4399 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4400 			    void *data, int len);
4401 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4402 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4403 			     void *data, int len);
4404 #endif
4405 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4406 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4407 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4408 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4409 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4410 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4411 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4412 
4413 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4414 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4415 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4416 				 int duration,
4417 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4418 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4419 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4420 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4421 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4422 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4423 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4424 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4425 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4426 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4427 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4428 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4429 
4430 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4431 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4432 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4433 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4434 				      bool more_data);
4435 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4437 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4438 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4439 					bool more_data);
4440 
4441 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4442 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4443 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4444 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4445 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4446 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4447 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4448 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4449 
4450 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4451 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4452 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4453 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4454 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4456 
4457 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4459 
4460 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4461 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4462 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4463 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4464 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4466 			       u32 changed);
4467 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4469 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4470 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4471 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4472 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4473 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4474 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4475 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4477 				  int n_vifs,
4478 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4479 
4480 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4481 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4482 
4483 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4484 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4486 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4487 #endif
4488 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4489 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4490 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4491 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4494 
4495 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4496 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4497 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4499 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4500 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4501 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4502 
4503 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4504 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4505 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4507 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4508 			   int *dbm);
4509 
4510 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4512 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4513 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4514 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4515 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4517 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4518 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4521 
4522 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4524 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4525 
4526 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4528 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4529 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4530 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4531 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4533 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4534 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4535 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4536 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4537 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 			    u8 instance_id);
4540 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4541 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4542 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4543 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4546 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4547 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4548 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4549 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4550 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4552 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4553 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4554 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4555 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4556 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4557 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4558 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4559 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4560 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4561 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4562 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4563 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4565 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4566 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4568 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4569 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4571 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4572 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4573 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4575 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4576 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4577 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4578 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4581 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4582 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4584 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4585 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4586 };
4587 
4588 /**
4589  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4590  *
4591  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4592  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4593  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4594  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4595  * @priv_data_len.
4596  *
4597  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4598  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4599  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4600  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4601  *
4602  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4603  */
4604 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4605 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4606 					   const char *requested_name);
4607 
4608 /**
4609  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4610  *
4611  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4612  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4613  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4614  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4615  * @priv_data_len.
4616  *
4617  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4618  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4619  *
4620  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4621  */
4622 static inline
4623 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4624 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4625 {
4626 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4627 }
4628 
4629 /**
4630  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4631  *
4632  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4633  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4634  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4635  *
4636  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4637  *
4638  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4639  */
4640 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4641 
4642 /**
4643  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4644  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4645  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4646  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4647  */
4648 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4649 	int throughput;
4650 	int blink_time;
4651 };
4652 
4653 /**
4654  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4655  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4656  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4657  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4658  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4659  */
4660 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4661 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4662 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4663 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4664 };
4665 
4666 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4667 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4668 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4669 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4670 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4671 const char *
4672 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4673 				   unsigned int flags,
4674 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4675 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4676 #endif
4677 /**
4678  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4679  *
4680  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4681  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4682  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4683  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4684  *
4685  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4686  *
4687  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4688  */
4689 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4690 {
4691 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4692 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4693 #else
4694 	return NULL;
4695 #endif
4696 }
4697 
4698 /**
4699  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4700  *
4701  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4702  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4703  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4704  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4705  *
4706  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4707  *
4708  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4709  */
4710 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4711 {
4712 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4713 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4714 #else
4715 	return NULL;
4716 #endif
4717 }
4718 
4719 /**
4720  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4721  *
4722  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4723  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4724  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4725  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4726  *
4727  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4728  *
4729  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4730  */
4731 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4732 {
4733 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4734 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4735 #else
4736 	return NULL;
4737 #endif
4738 }
4739 
4740 /**
4741  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4742  *
4743  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4744  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4745  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4746  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4747  *
4748  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4749  *
4750  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4751  */
4752 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4753 {
4754 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4755 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4756 #else
4757 	return NULL;
4758 #endif
4759 }
4760 
4761 /**
4762  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4763  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4764  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4765  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4766  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4767  *
4768  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4769  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4770  *
4771  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4772  */
4773 static inline const char *
4774 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4775 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4776 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4777 {
4778 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4779 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4780 						  blink_table_len);
4781 #else
4782 	return NULL;
4783 #endif
4784 }
4785 
4786 /**
4787  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4788  *
4789  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4790  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4791  *
4792  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4793  */
4794 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4795 
4796 /**
4797  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4798  *
4799  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4800  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4801  * before calling this function.
4802  *
4803  * @hw: the hardware to free
4804  */
4805 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4806 
4807 /**
4808  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4809  *
4810  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4811  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4812  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4813  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4814  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4815  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4816  *
4817  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4818  */
4819 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4820 
4821 /**
4822  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4823  *
4824  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4825  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4826  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4827  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4828  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4829  *
4830  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4831  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4832  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4833  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4834  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4835  *
4836  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4837  *
4838  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4839  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4840  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4841  * @list: the destination list
4842  */
4843 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4844 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4845 
4846 /**
4847  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4848  *
4849  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4850  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4851  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4852  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4853  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4854  *
4855  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4856  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4857  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4858  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4859  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4860  *
4861  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4862  *
4863  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4864  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4865  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4866  * @napi: the NAPI context
4867  */
4868 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4869 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4870 
4871 /**
4872  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4873  *
4874  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4875  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4876  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4877  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4878  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4879  *
4880  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4881  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4882  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4883  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4884  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4885  *
4886  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4887  *
4888  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4889  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4890  */
4891 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4892 {
4893 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4894 }
4895 
4896 /**
4897  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4898  *
4899  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4900  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4901  *
4902  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4903  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4904  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4905  *
4906  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4907  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4908  */
4909 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4910 
4911 /**
4912  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4913  *
4914  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4915  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4916  *
4917  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4918  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4919  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4920  *
4921  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4922  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4923  */
4924 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4925 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4926 {
4927 	local_bh_disable();
4928 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4929 	local_bh_enable();
4930 }
4931 
4932 /**
4933  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4934  *
4935  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4936  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4937  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4938  *
4939  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4940  *
4941  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4942  * each other.
4943  *
4944  * @sta: currently connected sta
4945  * @start: start or stop PS
4946  *
4947  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4948  */
4949 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4950 
4951 /**
4952  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4953  *                                  (in process context)
4954  *
4955  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4956  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4957  * applies.
4958  *
4959  * @sta: currently connected sta
4960  * @start: start or stop PS
4961  *
4962  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4963  */
4964 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4965 						  bool start)
4966 {
4967 	int ret;
4968 
4969 	local_bh_disable();
4970 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4971 	local_bh_enable();
4972 
4973 	return ret;
4974 }
4975 
4976 /**
4977  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4978  * @sta: currently connected station
4979  *
4980  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4981  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4982  * connected station was received.
4983  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4984  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4985  * be serialized.
4986  */
4987 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4988 
4989 /**
4990  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4991  * @sta: currently connected station
4992  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4993  *
4994  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4995  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4996  * from a connected station was received.
4997  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4998  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4999  * serialized.
5000  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5001  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5002  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5003  * checks.
5004  */
5005 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5006 
5007 /*
5008  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5009  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5010  */
5011 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5012 
5013 /**
5014  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5015  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5016  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5017  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5018  *
5019  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5020  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5021  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5022  *
5023  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5024  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5025  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5026  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5027  *
5028  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5029  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5030  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5031  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5032  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5033  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5034  *
5035  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5036  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5037  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5038  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5039  * use this API.
5040  */
5041 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5042 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5043 
5044 /**
5045  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5046  *
5047  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5048  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5049  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5050  *
5051  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5052  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5053  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5054  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5055  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5056  */
5057 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5058 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5059 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5060 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5061 			    int max_rates);
5062 
5063 /**
5064  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5065  *
5066  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5067  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5068  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5069  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5070  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5071  * slow stations to starve).
5072  *
5073  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5074  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5075  */
5076 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5077 					   u32 thr);
5078 
5079 /**
5080  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5081  *
5082  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5083  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5084  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5085  *
5086  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5087  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5088  * @info: tx status information
5089  */
5090 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5091 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5092 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5093 
5094 /**
5095  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5096  *
5097  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5098  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5099  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5100  *
5101  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5102  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5103  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5104  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5105  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5106  *
5107  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5108  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5109  */
5110 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5111 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5112 
5113 /**
5114  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5115  *
5116  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5117  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5118  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5119  *
5120  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5121  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5122  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5123  *
5124  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5125  * @status: tx status information
5126  */
5127 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5128 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5129 
5130 /**
5131  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5132  *
5133  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5134  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5135  * specific skbs.
5136  *
5137  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5138  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5139  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5140  *
5141  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5142  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5143  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5144  * @info: tx status information
5145  */
5146 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5147 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5148 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5149 {
5150 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5151 		.sta = sta,
5152 		.info = info,
5153 	};
5154 
5155 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5156 }
5157 
5158 /**
5159  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5160  *
5161  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5162  *
5163  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5164  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5165  * for a single hardware.
5166  *
5167  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5168  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5169  */
5170 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5171 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5172 {
5173 	local_bh_disable();
5174 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5175 	local_bh_enable();
5176 }
5177 
5178 /**
5179  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5180  *
5181  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5182  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5183  *
5184  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5185  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5186  *
5187  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5188  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5189  */
5190 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5191 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5192 
5193 /**
5194  * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5195  *
5196  * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5197  * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5198  * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5199  * 802.11 frames.
5200  *
5201  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5202  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5203  * calls in the same tx status family.
5204  *
5205  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5206  * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5207  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5208  */
5209 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5210 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5211 			       struct sk_buff *skb);
5212 
5213 /**
5214  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5215  *
5216  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5217  * connected STA.
5218  *
5219  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5220  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5221  */
5222 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5223 
5224 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5225 
5226 /**
5227  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5228  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5229  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5230  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5231  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5232  *	should be ignored.
5233  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5234  */
5235 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5236 	u16 tim_offset;
5237 	u16 tim_length;
5238 
5239 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5240 	u16 mbssid_off;
5241 };
5242 
5243 /**
5244  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5245  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5246  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5247  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5248  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5249  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5250  *
5251  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5252  * obtain the beacon template.
5253  *
5254  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5255  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5256  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5257  * applicable, the CSA count.
5258  *
5259  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5260  *
5261  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5262  */
5263 struct sk_buff *
5264 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5265 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5266 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5267 			      unsigned int link_id);
5268 
5269 /**
5270  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5271  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5272  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5273  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5274  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5275  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5276  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5277  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5278  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5279  *
5280  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5281  * obtain the beacon frame.
5282  *
5283  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5284  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5285  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5286  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5287  *
5288  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5289  *
5290  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5291  */
5292 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5293 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5294 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5295 					 unsigned int link_id);
5296 
5297 /**
5298  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5299  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5300  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5301  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5302  *
5303  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5304  *
5305  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5306  */
5307 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5308 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5309 						   unsigned int link_id)
5310 {
5311 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5312 }
5313 
5314 /**
5315  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5316  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5317  *
5318  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5319  * This function is called implicitly when
5320  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5321  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5322  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5323  *
5324  * Return: new countdown value
5325  */
5326 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5327 
5328 /**
5329  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5330  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5331  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5332  *
5333  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5334  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5335  *
5336  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5337  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5338  */
5339 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5340 
5341 /**
5342  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5343  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5344  *
5345  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5346  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5347  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5348  */
5349 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5350 
5351 /**
5352  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5353  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5354  *
5355  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5356  */
5357 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5358 
5359 /**
5360  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5361  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5362  *
5363  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5364  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5365  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5366  */
5367 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5368 
5369 /**
5370  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5371  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5372  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5373  *
5374  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5375  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5376  *
5377  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5378  *
5379  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5380  */
5381 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5382 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5383 
5384 /**
5385  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5386  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5387  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5388  *
5389  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5390  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5391  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5392  *
5393  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5394  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5395  *
5396  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5397  */
5398 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5399 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5400 
5401 /**
5402  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5403  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5404  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5405  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5406  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5407  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5408  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5409  *	if at all possible
5410  *
5411  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5412  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5413  * BSSID and address is used.
5414  *
5415  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5416  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5417  *
5418  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5419  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5420  *
5421  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5422  */
5423 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5424 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5425 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5426 
5427 /**
5428  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5429  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5430  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5431  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5432  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5433  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5434  *
5435  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5436  * hardware.
5437  *
5438  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5439  */
5440 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5441 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5442 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5443 				       size_t tailroom);
5444 
5445 /**
5446  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5447  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5448  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5449  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5450  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5451  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5452  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5453  *
5454  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5455  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5456  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5457  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5458  */
5459 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5460 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5461 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5462 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5463 
5464 /**
5465  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5466  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5467  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5468  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5469  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5470  *
5471  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5472  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5473  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5474  *
5475  * Return: The duration.
5476  */
5477 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5478 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5479 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5480 
5481 /**
5482  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5483  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5484  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5485  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5486  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5487  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5488  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5489  *
5490  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5491  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5492  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5493  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5494  */
5495 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5496 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5497 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5498 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5499 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5500 
5501 /**
5502  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5503  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5504  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5505  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5506  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5507  *
5508  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5509  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5510  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5511  *
5512  * Return: The duration.
5513  */
5514 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5515 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5516 				    size_t frame_len,
5517 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5518 
5519 /**
5520  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5521  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5522  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5523  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5524  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5525  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5526  *
5527  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5528  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5529  *
5530  * Return: The duration.
5531  */
5532 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5533 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5534 					enum nl80211_band band,
5535 					size_t frame_len,
5536 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5537 
5538 /**
5539  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5540  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5541  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5542  *
5543  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5544  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5545  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5546  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5547  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5548  *
5549  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5550  * frames are available.
5551  *
5552  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5553  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5554  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5555  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5556  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5557  * use common code for all beacons.
5558  */
5559 struct sk_buff *
5560 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5561 
5562 /**
5563  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5564  *
5565  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5566  *
5567  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5568  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5569  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5570  */
5571 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5572 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5573 
5574 /**
5575  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5576  *
5577  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5578  * from the given packet.
5579  *
5580  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5581  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5582  *	with this P1K
5583  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5584  */
5585 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5586 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5587 {
5588 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5589 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5590 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5591 
5592 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5593 }
5594 
5595 /**
5596  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5597  *
5598  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5599  * and transmitter address.
5600  *
5601  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5602  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5603  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5604  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5605  */
5606 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5607 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5608 
5609 /**
5610  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5611  *
5612  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5613  * in the packet.
5614  *
5615  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5616  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5617  *	encrypted with this key
5618  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5619  */
5620 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5621 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5622 
5623 /**
5624  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5625  *
5626  * @pos: start of crypto header
5627  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5628  * @pn: PN to add
5629  *
5630  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5631  * the packet payload)
5632  *
5633  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5634  * point to the crypto header)
5635  */
5636 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5637 
5638 /**
5639  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5640  *
5641  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5642  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5643  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5644  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5645  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5646  *
5647  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5648  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5649  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5650  *
5651  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5652  * can be done concurrently.
5653  */
5654 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5655 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5656 
5657 /**
5658  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5659  *
5660  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5661  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5662  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5663  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5664  * @seq: new sequence data
5665  *
5666  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5667  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5668  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5669  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5670  *
5671  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5672  * can be done concurrently.
5673  */
5674 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5675 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5676 
5677 /**
5678  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5679  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5680  *
5681  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5682  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5683  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5684  *
5685  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5686  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5687  */
5688 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5689 
5690 /**
5691  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5692  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5693  * @keyconf: new key data
5694  *
5695  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5696  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5697  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5698  *
5699  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5700  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5701  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5702  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5703  *
5704  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5705  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5706  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5707  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5708  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5709  * of the reconfiguration.
5710  *
5711  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5712  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5713  *
5714  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5715  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5716  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5717  * the key that's being replaced.
5718  */
5719 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5720 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5721 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5722 
5723 /**
5724  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5725  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5726  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5727  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5728  * @gfp: allocation flags
5729  */
5730 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5731 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5732 
5733 /**
5734  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5735  *
5736  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5737  * at the same time.
5738  *
5739  * @keyconf: the key in question
5740  */
5741 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5742 
5743 /**
5744  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5745  *
5746  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5747  * at the same time.
5748  *
5749  * @keyconf: the key in question
5750  */
5751 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5752 
5753 /**
5754  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5755  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5756  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5757  *
5758  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5759  */
5760 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5761 
5762 /**
5763  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5764  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5765  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5766  *
5767  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5768  */
5769 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5770 
5771 /**
5772  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5773  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5774  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5775  *
5776  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5777  *
5778  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5779  */
5780 
5781 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5782 
5783 /**
5784  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5785  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5786  *
5787  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5788  */
5789 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5790 
5791 /**
5792  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5793  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5794  *
5795  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5796  */
5797 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5798 
5799 /**
5800  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5801  *
5802  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5803  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5804  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5805  * any context, including hardirq context.
5806  *
5807  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5808  * @info: information about the completed scan
5809  */
5810 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5811 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5812 
5813 /**
5814  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5815  *
5816  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5817  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5818  *
5819  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5820  */
5821 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5822 
5823 /**
5824  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5825  *
5826  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5827  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5828  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5829  * while associating, for instance.
5830  *
5831  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5832  */
5833 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5834 
5835 /**
5836  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5837  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5838  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5839  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5840  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5841  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5842  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5843  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5844  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5845  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5846  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5847  *	for instance.
5848  */
5849 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5850 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5851 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5852 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5853 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5854 };
5855 
5856 /**
5857  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5858  *
5859  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5860  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5861  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5862  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5863  *
5864  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5865  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5866  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5867  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5868  */
5869 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5870 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5871 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5872 				  void *data);
5873 
5874 /**
5875  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5876  *
5877  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5878  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5879  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5880  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5881  * be used.
5882  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5883  *
5884  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5885  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5886  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5887  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5888  */
5889 static inline void
5890 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5891 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5892 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5893 				    void *data)
5894 {
5895 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5896 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5897 				     iterator, data);
5898 }
5899 
5900 /**
5901  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5902  *
5903  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5904  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5905  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5906  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5907  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5908  *
5909  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5910  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5911  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5912  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5913  */
5914 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5915 						u32 iter_flags,
5916 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5917 						    u8 *mac,
5918 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5919 						void *data);
5920 
5921 /**
5922  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5923  *
5924  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5925  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5926  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5927  *
5928  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5929  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5930  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5931  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5932  */
5933 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5934 					     u32 iter_flags,
5935 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5936 						u8 *mac,
5937 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5938 					     void *data);
5939 
5940 /**
5941  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5942  *
5943  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5944  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5945  * function for them.
5946  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5947  *
5948  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5949  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5950  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5951  */
5952 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5953 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5954 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5955 				       void *data);
5956 /**
5957  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5958  *
5959  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5960  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5961  *
5962  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5963  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5964  */
5965 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5966 
5967 /**
5968  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5969  *
5970  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5971  * workqueue.
5972  *
5973  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5974  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5975  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5976  */
5977 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5978 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5979 				  unsigned long delay);
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5983  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5984  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5985  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5986  *
5987  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5988  *
5989  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5990  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5991  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5992  */
5993 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5994 				  u16 timeout);
5995 
5996 /**
5997  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5998  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5999  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6000  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6001  *
6002  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6003  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6004  * from any context.
6005  */
6006 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6007 				      u16 tid);
6008 
6009 /**
6010  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6011  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6012  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6013  *
6014  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6015  *
6016  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6017  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6018  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6019  */
6020 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6021 
6022 /**
6023  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6024  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6025  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6026  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6027  *
6028  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6029  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6030  * can be called from any context.
6031  */
6032 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6033 				     u16 tid);
6034 
6035 /**
6036  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6037  *
6038  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6039  * @addr: station's address
6040  *
6041  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6042  *
6043  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6044  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6045  */
6046 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6047 					 const u8 *addr);
6048 
6049 /**
6050  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6051  *
6052  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6053  * @addr: remote station's address
6054  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6055  *
6056  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6057  *
6058  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6059  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6060  *
6061  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6062  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6063  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6064  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6065  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6066  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6067  *      is not reliable.
6068  *
6069  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6070  */
6071 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6072 					       const u8 *addr,
6073 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6074 
6075 /**
6076  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6077  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6078  * @addr: remote station's link address
6079  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6080  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6081  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6082  *
6083  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6084  */
6085 struct ieee80211_sta *
6086 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6087 				 const u8 *addr,
6088 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6089 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6090 
6091 /**
6092  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6093  * @hw: the hardware
6094  * @pubsta: the station
6095  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6096  *
6097  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6098  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6099  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6100  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6101  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6102  *
6103  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6104  * manner.
6105  *
6106  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6107  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6108  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6109  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6110  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6111  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6112  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6113  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6114  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6115  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6116  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6117  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6118  * woke up while blocked or not.
6119  */
6120 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6121 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6122 
6123 /**
6124  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6125  * @pubsta: the station
6126  *
6127  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6128  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6129  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6130  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6131  *
6132  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6133  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6134  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6135  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6136  *
6137  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6138  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6139  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6140  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6141  */
6142 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6143 
6144 /**
6145  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6146  * @pubsta: the station
6147  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6148  *
6149  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6150  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6151  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6152  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6153  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6154  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6155  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6156  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6157  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6158  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6159  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6160  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6161  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6162  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6163  */
6164 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6165 
6166 /**
6167  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6168  * @pubsta: the station
6169  *
6170  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6171  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6172  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6173  *
6174  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6175  * there is no need to call this function.
6176  */
6177 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6178 
6179 /**
6180  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6181  *
6182  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6183  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6184  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6185  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6186  *
6187  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6188  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6189  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6190  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6191  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6192  * attempts.
6193  *
6194  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6195  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6196  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6197  * them to 0.
6198  *
6199  * @pubsta: the station
6200  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6201  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6202  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6203  */
6204 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6205 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6206 
6207 /**
6208  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6209  *
6210  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6211  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6212  *
6213  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6214  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6215  */
6216 bool
6217 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6218 
6219 /**
6220  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6221  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6222  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6223  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6224  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6225  *
6226  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6227  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6228  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6229  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6230  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6231  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6232  *
6233  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6234  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6235  * set_key callback.
6236  */
6237 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6238 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6239 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6240 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6241 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6242 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6243 				      void *data),
6244 			 void *iter_data);
6245 
6246 /**
6247  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6248  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6249  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6250  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6251  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6252  *
6253  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6254  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6255  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6256  * in removal process will be skipped.
6257  *
6258  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6259  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6260  */
6261 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6262 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6263 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6264 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6265 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6266 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6267 					  void *data),
6268 			     void *iter_data);
6269 
6270 /**
6271  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6272  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6273  * @iter: iterator function
6274  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6275  *
6276  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6277  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6278  * places while calling into the driver.
6279  *
6280  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6281  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6282  * removed.
6283  *
6284  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6285  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6286  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6287  * or not.
6288  */
6289 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6290 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6291 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6292 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6293 		     void *data),
6294 	void *iter_data);
6295 
6296 /**
6297  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6298  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6299  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6300  *
6301  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6302  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6303  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6304  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6305  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6306  * %NULL.
6307  *
6308  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6309  */
6310 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6311 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6312 
6313 /**
6314  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6315  *
6316  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6317  *
6318  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6319  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6320  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6321  */
6322 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6323 
6324 /**
6325  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6326  *
6327  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6328  *
6329  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6330  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6331  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6332  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6333  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6334  *
6335  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6336  * without connection recovery attempts.
6337  */
6338 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6339 
6340 /**
6341  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6342  *
6343  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6344  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6345  *
6346  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6347  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6348  */
6349 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6350 
6351 /**
6352  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6353  *
6354  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6355  *
6356  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6357  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6358  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6359  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6360  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6361  *
6362  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6363  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6364  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6365  * disconnect normally later.
6366  *
6367  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6368  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6369  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6370  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6371  */
6372 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6373 
6374 /**
6375  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6376  * hardware restart
6377  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6378  *
6379  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6380  * hardware restart.
6381  */
6382 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6383 
6384 /**
6385  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6386  *	rssi threshold triggered
6387  *
6388  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6389  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6390  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6391  * @gfp: context flags
6392  *
6393  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6394  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6395  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6396  */
6397 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6398 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6399 			       s32 rssi_level,
6400 			       gfp_t gfp);
6401 
6402 /**
6403  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6404  *
6405  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6406  * @gfp: context flags
6407  */
6408 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6409 
6410 /**
6411  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6412  *
6413  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6414  */
6415 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6416 
6417 /**
6418  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6419  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6420  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6421  *
6422  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6423  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6424  */
6425 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6426 
6427 /**
6428  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6429  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6430  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6431  *
6432  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6433  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6434  * a deauth frame in this case.
6435  */
6436 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6437 					 bool block_tx);
6438 
6439 /**
6440  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6441  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6442  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6443  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6444  *
6445  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6446  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6447  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6448  */
6449 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6450 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6451 
6452 /**
6453  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6454  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6455  */
6456 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6457 
6458 /**
6459  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6460  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6461  */
6462 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6463 
6464 /**
6465  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6466  *
6467  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6468  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6469  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6470  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6471  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6472  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6473  *
6474  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6475  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6476  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6477  */
6478 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6479 				  const u8 *addr);
6480 
6481 /**
6482  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6483  * @pubsta: station struct
6484  * @tid: the session's TID
6485  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6486  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6487  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6488  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6489  *
6490  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6491  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6492  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6493  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6494  */
6495 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6496 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6497 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6498 
6499 /**
6500  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6501  *
6502  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6503  * buffer.
6504  *
6505  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6506  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6507  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6508  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6509  */
6510 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6511 
6512 /**
6513  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6514  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6515  * @addr: station mac address
6516  * @tid: the rx tid
6517  */
6518 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6519 				 unsigned int tid);
6520 
6521 /**
6522  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6523  *
6524  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6525  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6526  * reordering.
6527  *
6528  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6529  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6530  *
6531  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6532  * @addr: station mac address
6533  * @tid: the rx tid
6534  */
6535 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6536 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6537 {
6538 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6539 		return;
6540 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6541 }
6542 
6543 /**
6544  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6545  *
6546  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6547  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6548  * reordering.
6549  *
6550  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6551  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6552  *
6553  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6554  * @addr: station mac address
6555  * @tid: the rx tid
6556  */
6557 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6558 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6559 {
6560 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6561 		return;
6562 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6563 }
6564 
6565 /**
6566  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6567  *
6568  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6569  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6570  *
6571  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6572  *
6573  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6574  * @addr: station mac address
6575  * @tid: the rx tid
6576  */
6577 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6578 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6579 
6580 /* Rate control API */
6581 
6582 /**
6583  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6584  *
6585  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6586  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6587  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6588  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6589  *	to be filled in
6590  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6591  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6592  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6593  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6594  *	RTS threshold
6595  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6596  *	if the selected rate supports it
6597  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6598  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6599  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6600  */
6601 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6602 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6603 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6604 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6605 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6606 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6607 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6608 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6609 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6610 	bool bss;
6611 };
6612 
6613 /**
6614  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6615  */
6616 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6617 	/**
6618 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6619 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6620 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6621 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6622 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6623 	 */
6624 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6625 	/**
6626 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6627 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6628 	 */
6629 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6630 };
6631 
6632 struct rate_control_ops {
6633 	unsigned long capa;
6634 	const char *name;
6635 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6636 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6637 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6638 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6639 
6640 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6641 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6642 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6643 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6644 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6645 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6646 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6647 			    u32 changed);
6648 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6649 			 void *priv_sta);
6650 
6651 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6652 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6653 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6654 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6655 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6656 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6657 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6658 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6659 
6660 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6661 				struct dentry *dir);
6662 
6663 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6664 };
6665 
6666 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6667 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6668 				 int index)
6669 {
6670 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6671 }
6672 
6673 static inline s8
6674 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6675 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6676 {
6677 	int i;
6678 
6679 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6680 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6681 			return i;
6682 
6683 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6684 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6685 
6686 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6687 	return 0;
6688 }
6689 
6690 static inline
6691 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6692 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6693 {
6694 	unsigned int i;
6695 
6696 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6697 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6698 			return true;
6699 	return false;
6700 }
6701 
6702 /**
6703  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6704  *
6705  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6706  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6707  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6708  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6709  *
6710  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6711  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6712  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6713  */
6714 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6715 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6716 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6717 
6718 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6719 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6720 
6721 static inline bool
6722 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6723 {
6724 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6725 }
6726 
6727 static inline bool
6728 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6729 {
6730 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6731 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6732 }
6733 
6734 static inline bool
6735 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6736 {
6737 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6738 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6739 }
6740 
6741 static inline bool
6742 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6743 {
6744 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6745 }
6746 
6747 static inline bool
6748 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6749 {
6750 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6751 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6752 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6753 }
6754 
6755 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6756 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6757 {
6758 	if (p2p) {
6759 		switch (type) {
6760 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6761 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6762 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6763 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6764 		default:
6765 			break;
6766 		}
6767 	}
6768 	return type;
6769 }
6770 
6771 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6772 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6773 {
6774 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6775 }
6776 
6777 /**
6778  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6779  *
6780  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6781  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6782  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6783  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6784  *
6785  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6786  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6787  * matching GroupId management frame.
6788  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6789  */
6790 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6791 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6792 
6793 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6794 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6795 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6796 
6797 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6798 
6799 /**
6800  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6801  *
6802  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6803  *
6804  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6805  *
6806  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6807  * applicable.
6808  */
6809 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6810 
6811 /**
6812  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6813  * @vif: virtual interface
6814  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6815  * @gfp: allocation flags
6816  *
6817  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6818  */
6819 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6820 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6821 				    gfp_t gfp);
6822 
6823 /**
6824  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6825  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6826  * @vif: virtual interface
6827  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6828  * @band: the band to transmit on
6829  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6830  *
6831  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6832  */
6833 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6834 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6835 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6836 
6837 /**
6838  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6839  *				 of injected frames.
6840  *
6841  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6842  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6843  * of the skb before calling this function.
6844  *
6845  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6846  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6847  */
6848 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6849 				 struct net_device *dev);
6850 
6851 /**
6852  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6853  *
6854  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6855  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6856  *
6857  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6858  *
6859  * private:
6860  *
6861  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6862  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6863  */
6864 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6865 	u32 next_tsf;
6866 	bool has_next_tsf;
6867 
6868 	u8 absent;
6869 
6870 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6871 	struct {
6872 		u32 start;
6873 		u32 duration;
6874 		u32 interval;
6875 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6876 };
6877 
6878 /**
6879  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6880  *
6881  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6882  * @data: NoA tracking data
6883  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6884  *
6885  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6886  */
6887 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6888 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6889 
6890 /**
6891  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6892  *
6893  * @data: NoA tracking data
6894  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6895  */
6896 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6897 
6898 /**
6899  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6900  * @vif: virtual interface
6901  * @peer: the peer's destination address
6902  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6903  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6904  * @gfp: allocation flags
6905  *
6906  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6907  */
6908 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6909 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6910 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6911 
6912 /**
6913  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6914  *
6915  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6916  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6917  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6918  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6919  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6920  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6921  *
6922  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6923  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6924  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6925  *
6926  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6927  * @tid: the TID to reserve
6928  *
6929  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6930  */
6931 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6932 
6933 /**
6934  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6935  *
6936  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6937  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6938  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6939  *
6940  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6941  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6942  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6943  *
6944  * @sta: the station
6945  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6946  */
6947 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6948 
6949 /**
6950  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6951  *
6952  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6953  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6954  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6955  *
6956  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6957  *
6958  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6959  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6960  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6961  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6962  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6963  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6964  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6965  *
6966  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6967  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6968  */
6969 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6970 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6971 
6972 /**
6973  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6974  * (in process context)
6975  *
6976  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6977  * (internally disables bottom halves).
6978  *
6979  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6980  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6981  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6982  */
6983 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6984 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6985 {
6986 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6987 
6988 	local_bh_disable();
6989 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6990 	local_bh_enable();
6991 
6992 	return skb;
6993 }
6994 
6995 /**
6996  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
6997  *
6998  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
6999  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7000  *
7001  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7002  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7003  */
7004 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7005 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7006 
7007 /**
7008  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7009  *
7010  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7011  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7012  *
7013  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7014  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7015  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7016  */
7017 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7018 
7019 /**
7020  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7021  *
7022  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7023  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7024  *
7025  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7026  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7027  */
7028 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7029 
7030 /* (deprecated) */
7031 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7032 {
7033 }
7034 
7035 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7036 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7037 
7038 /**
7039  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7040  *
7041  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7042  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7043  *
7044  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7045  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7046  *
7047  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7048  * this TXQ internally.
7049  */
7050 static inline void
7051 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7052 {
7053 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7054 }
7055 
7056 /**
7057  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7058  *
7059  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7060  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7061  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7062  *
7063  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7064  * internally.
7065  */
7066 static inline void
7067 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7068 		     bool force)
7069 {
7070 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7071 }
7072 
7073 /**
7074  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7075  *
7076  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7077  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7078  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7079  * next_txq().
7080  *
7081  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7082  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7083  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7084  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7085  * again.
7086  *
7087  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7088  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7089  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7090  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7091  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7092  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7093  *
7094  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7095  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7096  */
7097 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7098 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7099 
7100 /**
7101  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7102  *
7103  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7104  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7105  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7106  *
7107  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7108  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7109  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7110  */
7111 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7112 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7113 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7114 
7115 /**
7116  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7117  *
7118  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7119  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7120  *
7121  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7122  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7123  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7124  * @gfp: allocation flags
7125  */
7126 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7127 				   u8 inst_id,
7128 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7129 				   gfp_t gfp);
7130 
7131 /**
7132  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7133  *
7134  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7135  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7136  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7137  *
7138  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7139  * @match: match event information
7140  * @gfp: allocation flags
7141  */
7142 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7143 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7144 			      gfp_t gfp);
7145 
7146 /**
7147  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7148  *
7149  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7150  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7151  *
7152  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7153  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7154  *          information.
7155  * @len: frame length in bytes
7156  */
7157 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7158 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7159 			      int len);
7160 
7161 /**
7162  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7163  *
7164  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7165  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7166  *
7167  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7168  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7169  * @len: frame length in bytes
7170  */
7171 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7172 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7173 			      int len);
7174 /**
7175  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7176  *
7177  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7178  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7179  * hardware or firmware.
7180  *
7181  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7182  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7183  */
7184 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7185 
7186 /**
7187  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7188  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7189  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7190  *
7191  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7192  *
7193  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7194  */
7195 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7196 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7197 
7198 /**
7199  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7200  *	probe response template.
7201  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7202  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7203  *
7204  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7205  *
7206  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7207  */
7208 struct sk_buff *
7209 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7210 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7211 
7212 /**
7213  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7214  * collision.
7215  *
7216  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7217  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7218  *	aware of.
7219  * @gfp: allocation flags
7220  */
7221 void
7222 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7223 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7224 
7225 /**
7226  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7227  *
7228  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7229  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7230  *
7231  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7232  */
7233 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7234 {
7235 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7236 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7237 
7238 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7239 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7240 }
7241 
7242 /**
7243  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7244  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7245  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7246  *
7247  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7248  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7249  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7250  *
7251  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7252  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7253  * a sequence of calls like
7254  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7255  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7256  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7257  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7258  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7259  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7260  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7261  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7262  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7263  *
7264  * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7265  *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7266  *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7267  */
7268 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7269 
7270 /**
7271  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7272  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7273  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7274  *
7275  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7276  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7277  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7278  * completed after it returns.
7279  */
7280 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7281 				      u16 active_links);
7282 
7283 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7284